blob: 8b2e0203b38e2b90bf9075bde7291d908fc09a89 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000062 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000478 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000479 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000480 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
481 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000483 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000485 << D->getIdentifier();
486 return ExprError();
487 }
488 }
489 }
490 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000491
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000492 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000493
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000494 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
495 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
496 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000497 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000498}
499
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000500/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
501/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
502/// actual member.
503///
504/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
505/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
506/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
507/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
508/// we found.
509///
510/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
511/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
512/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
513VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
514 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000515 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
516 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
517 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
518
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000519 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000520 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
521 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
522 do {
523 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000524 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000525 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000526 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 else {
528 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
529 break;
530 }
531 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000532 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534
535 return BaseObject;
536}
537
538Sema::OwningExprResult
539Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
540 FieldDecl *Field,
541 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
542 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
543 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000544 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545 AnonFields);
546
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000547 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
548 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
549 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
550 // found via name lookup.
551 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000552 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 if (BaseObject) {
554 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
555 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000556 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000557 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000558 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000559 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000560 BaseQuals
561 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000562 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
563 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
564 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
565 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
566 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000567 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
569 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
570 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000571 BaseQuals
572 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000573 } else {
574 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
575 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
576 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000577 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
578 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000579 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000580 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000581 = Context.getTagDeclType(
582 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
583 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000584 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000585 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
586 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
587 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000588 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000589 MD->getThisType(Context),
590 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000591 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
592 }
593 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000594 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
595 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000597 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 }
599
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000600 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000601 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
602 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000603 }
604
605 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
606 // anonymous struct/union.
607 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000608 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
610 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
611 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
612 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000613 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
614 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
615
616 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
617 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
618 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
619 ResultQuals.removeConst();
620
621 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
622 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
623
624 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
625 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
626
627 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
628 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
629 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
630
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000631 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000632 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000633 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000634 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
635 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000636 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000637 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000638 }
639
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000640 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000641}
642
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000643/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
644/// possibly a list of template arguments.
645///
646/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
647/// DecomposeTemplateName.
648///
649/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
650/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
651/// some way.
652static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
653 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
654 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
655 DeclarationName &Name,
656 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
657 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
658 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
659 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
660 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
661
662 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
663 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
664 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
665 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
666 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
667
668 TemplateName TName =
669 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
670
671 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
672 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
673 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
674 } else {
675 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
676 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
677 TemplateArgs = 0;
678 }
679}
680
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000681/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
682/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
683/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000685 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
686 return false;
687
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000688 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
689 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
690 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
691 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
692 if (!BaseRT) return false;
693
694 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000695 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000696 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
697 return false;
698 }
699
700 return true;
701}
702
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000703/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
704/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
705static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000707
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000708 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
709 if (!DC) return true;
710
711 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
712 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
713
714 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
715 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
716
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000717 return false;
718}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000719
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000720/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
721/// the prospective base classes.
722static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
723 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
724 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000725 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000726 return false;
727
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000728 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000729 if (!RD) return false;
730 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
731
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000732 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
733 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
734 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
735 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
736 if (!BaseRT) return false;
737
738 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
740 return false;
741 }
742
743 return true;
744}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000745
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000746enum IMAKind {
747 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
748 IMA_Static,
749
750 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
751 IMA_Mixed,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
754 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
755 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
756
757 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
758 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
759 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
760
761 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
762 IMA_Instance,
763
764 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
765 IMA_Unresolved,
766
767 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
768 /// context is not an instance method.
769 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
770
771 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
772 /// non-class context.
773 IMA_AnonymousMember,
774
775 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
776 /// context is not an instance method.
777 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
778
779 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
780 /// class.
781 IMA_Error_Unrelated
782};
783
784/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
785/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
786/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
787/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
788/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
789/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
790static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
791 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000792 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000793
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000794 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000795 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000796 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
797 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000798
799 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
800 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
801
802 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
803 bool hasNonInstance = false;
804 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
805 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000806 NamedDecl *D = *I;
807 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000808 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
809
810 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
811 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
812 // that's a special case.
813 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
814 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
815 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
816 }
817 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
818 }
819 else
820 hasNonInstance = true;
821 }
822
823 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
824 // member reference.
825 if (Classes.empty())
826 return IMA_Static;
827
828 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
829 // an implicit member reference.
830 if (isStaticContext)
831 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
832
833 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
834 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
835 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
836 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000837 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000838 Classes))
839 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
840
841 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
842}
843
844/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
845static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
846 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
847 const LookupResult &R) {
848 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
849 SourceRange Range(Loc);
850 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
851
852 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
853 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
854 if (MD->isStatic()) {
855 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
856 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
857 << Range << R.getLookupName();
858 return;
859 }
860 }
861
862 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
863 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
864 return;
865 }
866
867 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000868}
869
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000870/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
871///
872/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000873bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
874 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
876
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000877 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000878 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000879 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
880 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000881 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000882 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000883 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
884 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000885
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000886 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
887 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
888 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
889 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000890 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000891 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000892 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
893 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
894
895 if (!R.empty()) {
896 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
897 R.suppressDiagnostics();
898
899 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
900 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
901 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
902 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
903
904 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
905 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
906 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000907 if (isInstance) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000908 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000909 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000910
911 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
912 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
913 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
914 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
915 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
916 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(R.getNameLoc(),
917 DepThisType, false);
918 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
919 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
920 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
921 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
922 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
923 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
924 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL, Name,
925 R.getNameLoc(), &TList);
926 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
927 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000928 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000929 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000930
931 // Do we really want to note all of these?
932 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
933 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
934
935 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
936 return false;
937 }
938 }
939 }
940
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000941 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000942 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000943 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000944 if (!R.empty()) {
945 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
946 if (SS.isEmpty())
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
948 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
949 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
950 else
951 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
952 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
953 << SS.getRange()
954 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
955 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
956 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
957 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
958 << ND->getDeclName();
959
960 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
961 return false;
962 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000963
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
965 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
966 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
967 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
968 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
969 // to recover well anyway.
970 if (SS.isEmpty())
971 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange();
976
977 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
978 return true;
979 }
980 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000981 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000982 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000983 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000984 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000985 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000987 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
988 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000989 return true;
990 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000991 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000992 }
993
994 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
995 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
996 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
998 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
999 << SS.getRange();
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001003 // Give up, we can't recover.
1004 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1005 return true;
1006}
1007
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001008static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
1009 IdentifierInfo *II,
1010 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1011 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1012 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1013 if (!IDecl)
1014 return 0;
1015 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1016 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1017 return 0;
1018 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1019 if (!property)
1020 return 0;
1021 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1022 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1023 return 0;
1024 return property;
1025}
1026
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001027static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001028 IdentifierInfo *II,
1029 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1030 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1031 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1032 if (!IDecl)
1033 return 0;
1034 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001035 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1036 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001037 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1038 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1039 if (!property)
1040 return 0;
1041 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1042 DynamicImplSeen =
1043 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1044 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001045 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1046 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001047 NameLoc,
1048 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1049 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1050 (Expr *)0, true);
1051 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1052 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1053 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1054 return Ivar;
1055 }
1056 return 0;
1057}
1058
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001059Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001060 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001061 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1062 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1063 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1064 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1065 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1066
1067 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001068 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001069
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001070 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001071
1072 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1073 DeclarationName Name;
1074 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1075 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001076 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1077 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001078
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001079 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001080
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001081 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1082 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001083 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1084 // (note: handled after lookup)
1085 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1086 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1087 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001088 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1089 // names a dependent type.
1090 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1091 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001092 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1093 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1094 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001095 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001096 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001097 TemplateArgs);
1098 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001099 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001100 // Perform the required lookup.
1101 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1102 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001103 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1104 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1105 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1106 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1107 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001108 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1109 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1110 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001111 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001112 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001113 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001114
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001115 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1116 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001117 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1118 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001119 if (E.isInvalid())
1120 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001121
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001122 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1123 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001124 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1125 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001126 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001127 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1128 isAddressOfOperand);
1129 }
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001130 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001131 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001132
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1134 return ExprError();
1135
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001136 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1137 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001138 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001139
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001140 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001141 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001142 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1143 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1144 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1145 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1146 }
1147
1148 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1149 // call, diagnose the problem.
1150 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001151 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001152 return ExprError();
1153
1154 assert(!R.empty() &&
1155 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001156
1157 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1158 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001159 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001160 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1161 R.clear();
1162 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1163 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1164 return move(E);
1165 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001166 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001167 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001168
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001169 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1170 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1171
1172 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001173 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
1174 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
1175 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1176 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1177 if (Property) {
1178 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1179 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
1180 }
1181 }
1182
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001183 // Warn about constructs like:
1184 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1185 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001186 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1187 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001188 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001189 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001190 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001191 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001192 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001193 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1194 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001195 break;
1196 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001197
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001198 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1199 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001200 }
1201 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001202 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001203 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1204 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1205 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1206 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1207 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1208 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001209 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001210 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001211
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001212 QualType T = Func->getType();
1213 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001214 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001215 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1216 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001217 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001218 }
1219 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001220
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001221 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1222 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1223 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1224 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1225 // class member access expression.
1226 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1227 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001228 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001229 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001230 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1231 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001232 }
1233
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001234 if (TemplateArgs)
1235 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001236
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001237 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1238}
1239
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001240/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1241Sema::OwningExprResult
1242Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1243 LookupResult &R,
1244 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1245 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1246 case IMA_Instance:
1247 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1248
1249 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1250 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1251 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1252 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1253
1254 case IMA_Mixed:
1255 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1256 case IMA_Unresolved:
1257 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1258
1259 case IMA_Static:
1260 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1261 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1262 if (TemplateArgs)
1263 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1264 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1265
1266 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1267 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1268 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1269 return ExprError();
1270 }
1271
1272 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1273 return ExprError();
1274}
1275
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001276/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1277/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1278/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1279/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001280Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001281Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001282 DeclarationName Name,
1283 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1284 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001285 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001286 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1287
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001288 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001289 return ExprError();
1290
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001291 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1292 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1293
1294 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1295 return ExprError();
1296
1297 if (R.empty()) {
1298 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1299 return ExprError();
1300 }
1301
1302 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1303}
1304
1305/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1306/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1307/// additional lookup.
1308///
1309/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1310/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1311///
1312/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1313Sema::OwningExprResult
1314Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001315 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001316 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001317 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001318
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001319 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1320 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1321 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1322 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1323 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1324
1325 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1326 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1327 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001328 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001329
1330 bool LookForIvars;
1331 if (Lookup.empty())
1332 LookForIvars = true;
1333 else if (IsClassMethod)
1334 LookForIvars = false;
1335 else
1336 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1337 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001338 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001339 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001340 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001341 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1342 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1343 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1344 if (IsClassMethod)
1345 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1346 << IV->getDeclName());
1347
1348 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1349 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1350 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1351 return ExprError();
1352
1353 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1354 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1355 return ExprError();
1356
1357 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1358 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1359 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1360 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1361
1362 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1363 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1364 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1365 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001366 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001367 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1368 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1369 SelfName, false, false);
1370 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1371 return Owned(new (Context)
1372 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1373 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1374 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001375 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001376 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001377 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001378 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1379 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1380 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1381 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1382 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1383 }
1384 }
1385
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001386 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1387 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1388 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1389 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1390 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1391 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1392 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1393 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1394 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1395 }
1396 }
1397 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001398 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1399 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001400}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001401
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001402/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1403///
1404/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1405///
1406/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1407/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1408/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1409/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1410///
1411/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1412/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1413/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1414/// the class declaring the member.
1415///
1416/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1417/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1418/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001419bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001420Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1421 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001422 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001423 NamedDecl *Member) {
1424 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1425 if (!RD)
1426 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001427
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001428 QualType DestRecordType;
1429 QualType DestType;
1430 QualType FromRecordType;
1431 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1432 bool PointerConversions = false;
1433 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1434 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001435
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001436 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1437 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1438 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1439 PointerConversions = true;
1440 } else {
1441 DestType = DestRecordType;
1442 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001443 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001444 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1445 if (Method->isStatic())
1446 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001447
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001448 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1449 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001450
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001451 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1452 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1453 PointerConversions = true;
1454 } else {
1455 FromRecordType = FromType;
1456 DestType = DestRecordType;
1457 }
1458 } else {
1459 // No conversion necessary.
1460 return false;
1461 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001462
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001463 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1464 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001465
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001466 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1467 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1468 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001469
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001470 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1471 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1472
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001473 ImplicitCastExpr::ResultCategory Category = CastCategory(From);
1474
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001475 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001476 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001477 // class name.
1478 //
1479 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1480 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1481 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1482 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1483 //
1484 // class Base { public: int x; };
1485 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1486 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1487 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1488 //
1489 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1490 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1491 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1492 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001493 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001494 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1495 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1496 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1497
1498 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1499
1500 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1501 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1502 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1503 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001504 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001505 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001506 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001507 return true;
1508
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001509 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001510 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001511 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001512 Category, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001513
1514 FromType = QType;
1515 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1516
1517 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1518 // we're done.
1519 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1520 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001521 }
1522 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001523
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001524 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001525
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001526 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1527 // down to the using declaration's type.
1528 //
1529 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1530 // class ever has member declarations.
1531 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1532 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1533 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1534 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1535
1536 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1537 // conversion is non-trivial.
1538 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1539 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001540 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001541 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001542 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001543 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001544
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001545 QualType UType = URecordType;
1546 if (PointerConversions)
1547 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001548 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001549 Category, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001550 FromType = UType;
1551 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1552 }
1553
1554 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1555 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1556 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001557 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001558
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001559 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1560 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1561 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001562 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001563 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001564
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001565 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001566 Category, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001567 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001568}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001569
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001570/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001571static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001572 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001573 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1574 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001575 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1576 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1577 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001578 if (SS.isSet()) {
1579 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1580 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001581 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001582
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001583 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001584 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001585}
1586
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001587/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1588/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1589/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1590/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001591Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001592Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1593 LookupResult &R,
1594 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1595 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001596 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1597
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001598 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001599
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001600 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1601 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001602 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001603 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001604 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001605 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001606 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001607
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001608 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1609 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001610 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1611 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001612 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1613 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001614 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1615 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1616 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1617 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001618 }
1619
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001620 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1621 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1622 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001623 SS,
1624 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1625 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001626}
1627
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001628bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001629 const LookupResult &R,
1630 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001631 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1632 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1633 return false;
1634
1635 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001636 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001637 return false;
1638
1639 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001640 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001641 return false;
1642
1643 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1644 // normal lookup:
1645 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1646 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1647
1648 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1649 // -- a declaration of a class member
1650 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1651 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001652 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001653 return false;
1654
1655 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1656 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1657 // using-declaration
1658 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1659 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1660 // turn off ADL anyway).
1661 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1662 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1663 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1664 return false;
1665
1666 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1667 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1668 // template
1669 // And also for builtin functions.
1670 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1671 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1672
1673 // But also builtin functions.
1674 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1675 return false;
1676 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1677 return false;
1678 }
1679
1680 return true;
1681}
1682
1683
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1685/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1686/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1687/// will in fact be used.
1688static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1689 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1690 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1691 return true;
1692 }
1693
1694 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1695 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1696 return true;
1697 }
1698
1699 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1700 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1701 return true;
1702 }
1703
1704 return false;
1705}
1706
1707Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001708Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001709 LookupResult &R,
1710 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001711 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1712 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001713 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001714 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001715
1716 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1717 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1718 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001719 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1720 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001721 return ExprError();
1722
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001723 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1724 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1725 // we've picked a target.
1726 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1727
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001728 bool Dependent
1729 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001730 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001731 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001732 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1733 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001734 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001735 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1736 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001737
1738 return Owned(ULE);
1739}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001740
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001741
1742/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1743Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001744Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001745 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1746 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001747 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1748 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001749
1750 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1751 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001752
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001753 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1754 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1755 // a template argument list.
1756 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1757 << Template << SS.getRange();
1758 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1759 return ExprError();
1760 }
1761
1762 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1763 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1764 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001765 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001766 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001767 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001768 return ExprError();
1769 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001770
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001771 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1772 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1773 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1774 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001775 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001776 return ExprError();
1777
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001778 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1779 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001780 return ExprError();
1781
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001782 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1783 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1784 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1785 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001786 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001787 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1788 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1789 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001790 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001791 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001792 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1793 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1794 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1795 return ExprError();
1796 }
1797
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001798 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001799 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1800 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1801 return ExprError();
1802 }
1803
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001804 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001805 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001806 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001807 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001808 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001809 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1810 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001811 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001812
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001813 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001814 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001815 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1816 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001817 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001818 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1819 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1820 Expr *E = new (Context)
1821 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1822 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001823
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001824 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
1825 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001826 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001827 SourceLocation(),
1828 Owned(E));
1829 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1830 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
1831 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1832 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1833 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001834 }
1835 }
1836 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001837 }
1838 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1839 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001840
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001841 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001842}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001843
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001844Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1845 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001846 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001847
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001848 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001849 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001850 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1851 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1852 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001853 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001854
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001855 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1856 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001857
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001858 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001859 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1860 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001861 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001862 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001863 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001864 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001865
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001866 QualType ResTy;
1867 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1868 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1869 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001870 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001871
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001872 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001873 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001874 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1875 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001876 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001877}
1878
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001879Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001880 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001881 bool Invalid = false;
1882 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1883 if (Invalid)
1884 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001885
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001886 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1887 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001888 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001889 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001890
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001891 QualType Ty;
1892 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1893 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1894 else if (Literal.isWide())
1895 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001896 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1897 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001898 else
1899 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001900
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001901 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1902 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001903 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001904}
1905
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001906Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1907 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001908 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1909 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001910 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001911 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001912 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001913 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001914 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001915
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001916 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001917 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1918 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001919 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001920
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001921 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001922 bool Invalid = false;
1923 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1924 if (Invalid)
1925 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001926
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001927 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001928 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001929 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001930 return ExprError();
1931
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001932 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001933
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001934 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001935 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001936 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001937 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001938 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001939 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001940 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001941 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001942
1943 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1944
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001945 using llvm::APFloat;
1946 APFloat Val(Format);
1947
1948 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001949
1950 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1951 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1952 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1953 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001954 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001955 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001956 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001957 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001958 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1959 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001960 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001961 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1962 }
1963
1964 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1965 << Ty
1966 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1967 }
1968
1969 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001970 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001972 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001973 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001974 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001975 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001976
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001977 // long long is a C99 feature.
1978 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001979 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001980 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1981
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001982 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001983 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001984
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001985 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1986 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1987 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001988 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1989 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001990 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001991 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001992 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1993 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001994
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001995 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1996 // be an unsigned int.
1997 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1998
1999 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002000 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002001 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2002 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002003 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002004
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002005 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2006 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2007 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2008 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002009 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002010 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002011 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002012 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002013 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002014 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002015
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002016 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002017 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002018 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002019
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002020 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2021 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2022 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2023 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002024 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002025 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002026 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002027 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002028 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002029 }
2030
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002031 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002032 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002033 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002034
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002035 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2036 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2037 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2038 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002039 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002040 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002041 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002042 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002043 }
2044 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002045
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002046 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2047 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002048 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002049 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002050 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002051 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002052 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002053
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002054 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2055 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002056 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002057 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002058 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002059
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002060 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2061 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002062 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002063 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002064
2065 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002066}
2067
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002068Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2069 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002070 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002071 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002072 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002073}
2074
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002075/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002076/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002077bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002078 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2079 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2080 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002081 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2082 return false;
2083
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002084 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2085 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2086 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2087 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2088 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2089 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2090
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002091 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002092 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002093 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002094 if (isSizeof)
2095 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2096 return false;
2097 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002098
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002099 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002100 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002101 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2102 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002103 return false;
2104 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002105
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002106 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002107 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2108 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002109 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002110
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002111 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002112 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002113 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002114 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2115 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002116 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002117
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002118 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2119 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2120 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2121 return true;
2122 }
2123
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002124 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002125}
2126
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002127bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2128 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2129 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002130
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002131 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002132 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2133 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002134
2135 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2136 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2137 return false;
2138
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002139 if (E->getBitField()) {
2140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2141 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002142 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002143
2144 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2145 // bit-field.
2146 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002147 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002148 return false;
2149
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002150 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2151}
2152
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002153/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002154Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002155Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002156 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002157 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002158 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002159 return ExprError();
2160
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002161 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002162
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002163 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2164 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2165 return ExprError();
2166
2167 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002168 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002169 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2170 R.getEnd()));
2171}
2172
2173/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2174/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002175Action::OwningExprResult
2176Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002177 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2178 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2179 bool isInvalid = false;
2180 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2181 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2182 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2183 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002184 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002185 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2186 isInvalid = true;
2187 } else {
2188 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2189 }
2190
2191 if (isInvalid)
2192 return ExprError();
2193
2194 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2195 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2196 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2197 R.getEnd()));
2198}
2199
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002200/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2201/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2202/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002203Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002204Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2205 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002206 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002207 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002208
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002209 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002210 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2211 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2212 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002213 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002214
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002215 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2216 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2217 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2218
2219 if (Result.isInvalid())
2220 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2221
2222 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002223}
2224
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002225QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002226 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2227 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002228
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002229 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002230 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002231 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002232
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002233 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2234 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2235 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002236
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002237 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002238 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2239 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002240 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002241}
2242
2243
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002244
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002245Action::OwningExprResult
2246Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2247 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002248 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2249 switch (Kind) {
2250 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2251 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2252 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2253 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002254
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002255 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002256}
2257
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002258Action::OwningExprResult
2259Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2260 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002261 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2262 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2263
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002264 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2265 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002266
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002267 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002268 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2269 Base.release();
2270 Idx.release();
2271 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2272 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2273 }
2274
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002275 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002276 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002277 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2278 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2279 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002280 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002281 }
2282
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002283 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2284}
2285
2286
2287Action::OwningExprResult
2288Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2289 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2290 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2291 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2292
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002293 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002294 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2295 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2296 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002297
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002298 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002299
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002300 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002301 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002302 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002303 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002304 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2305 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002306 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2307 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2308 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2309 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002310 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002311 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2312 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002313 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002314 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002315 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002316 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2317 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002318 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002319 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002320 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002321 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2322 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2323 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002324 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002325 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002326 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2327 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2328 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2329 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002330 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002331 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002332 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002333
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002334 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2335 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002336 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2337 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002338 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002339 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2340 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2341 // force the promotion here.
2342 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2343 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002344 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2345 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002346 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2347
2348 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2349 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002350 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002351 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2352 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2353 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2354 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002355 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2356 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002357 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2358
2359 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2360 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002361 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002362 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002363 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2364 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002365 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002366 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002367 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002368 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2369 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002370
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002371 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002372 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2373 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002374 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2375
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002376 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002377 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2378 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002379 // incomplete types are not object types.
2380 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2381 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2382 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2383 return ExprError();
2384 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002385
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002386 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002387 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002388 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2389 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002390 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002391
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002392 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002393 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002394 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2395 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2396 return ExprError();
2397 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002398
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002399 Base.release();
2400 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002401 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002402 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002403}
2404
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002405QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002406CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002407 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002408 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002409 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2410 // see FIXME there.
2411 //
2412 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2413 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002414 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002415
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002416 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002417 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002418
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002419 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002420 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2421 // to be selected.
2422 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002423
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002424 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2425 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002426 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002427
2428 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2429 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002430 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002431 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2432 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002433 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002434 do
2435 compStr++;
2436 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002437 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002438 do
2439 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002440 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002441 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002442
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002443 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002444 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2445 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002446 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2447 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002448 return QualType();
2449 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002450
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002451 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2452 // operates on.
2453 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002454 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002455
2456 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002457 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002458
2459 while (*compStr) {
2460 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2461 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2462 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2463 return QualType();
2464 }
2465 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002466 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002467
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002468 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002469 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002470 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002471 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002472 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002473 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002474 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002475 if (HexSwizzle)
2476 CompSize--;
2477
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002478 if (CompSize == 1)
2479 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002480
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002481 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002482 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002483 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2484 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2485 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2486 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002487 }
2488 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002489}
2490
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002491static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002492 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002493 const Selector &Sel,
2494 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002495
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002496 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002497 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002498 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002499 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002500
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002501 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2502 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002503 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002504 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002505 return D;
2506 }
2507 return 0;
2508}
2509
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002510static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002511 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002512 const Selector &Sel,
2513 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002514 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2515 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002516 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002517 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002518 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002519 GDecl = PD;
2520 break;
2521 }
2522 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002523 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002524 GDecl = OMD;
2525 break;
2526 }
2527 }
2528 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002529 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002530 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2531 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002532 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002533 if (GDecl)
2534 return GDecl;
2535 }
2536 }
2537 return GDecl;
2538}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002539
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002540Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002541Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2542 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002543 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2544 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2545 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2546 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2547 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2548
2549 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2550 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2551 //
2552 // T* t;
2553 // t.f;
2554 //
2555 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2556 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2557 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2558 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002559 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002560 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2561 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002562 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002563 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002564 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002565 return ExprError();
2566 }
2567 }
2568
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002569 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002570 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002571
2572 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2573 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002574 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002575 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2576 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2577 SS.getRange(),
2578 FirstQualifierInScope,
2579 Name, NameLoc,
2580 TemplateArgs));
2581}
2582
2583/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2584/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2585/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2586static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2587 Expr *BaseExpr,
2588 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002589 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002590 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002591 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2592 // diagnostics.
2593 if (!BaseExpr)
2594 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002595
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002596 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2597 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002598}
2599
2600// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2601// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2602// type. The restriction here is:
2603//
2604// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2605// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2606// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2607//
2608// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2609// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2610// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2611// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2612bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2613 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002614 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002615 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002616 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2617 if (!BaseRT) {
2618 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2619 // dependent.
2620 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2621 return false;
2622 }
2623 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002624
2625 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002626 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2627 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002628 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002629 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002631 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2632 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2633 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2634 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2635
2636 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2637 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2638
2639 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2640 return false;
2641 }
2642
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002643 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002644 return true;
2645}
2646
2647static bool
2648LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2649 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002650 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2651 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002652 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2653 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002654 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002655 << BaseRange))
2656 return true;
2657
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002658 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2659 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2660 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2661
2662 bool MOUS;
2663 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2664 return false;
2665 }
2666
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002667 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2668 if (SS.isSet()) {
2669 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2670 // nested-name-specifier.
2671 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2672
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002673 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002674 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2675 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2676 return true;
2677 }
2678
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002679 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002680
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002681 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2682 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2683 << DC << SS.getRange();
2684 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002685 }
2686 }
2687
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2689 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002690
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002691 if (!R.empty())
2692 return false;
2693
2694 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2695 // for typos.
2696 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002697 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002698 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002699 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2700 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2701 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002702 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2703 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002704 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2705 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2706 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002707 return false;
2708 } else {
2709 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002710 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002711 }
2712
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002713 return false;
2714}
2715
2716Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002717Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002718 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002719 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002720 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2721 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2722 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2723 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2724
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002725 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2726 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002727 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002728 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2729 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2730 Name, NameLoc,
2731 TemplateArgs);
2732
2733 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002734
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002735 // Implicit member accesses.
2736 if (!Base) {
2737 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2738 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2739 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2740 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002741 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002742 return ExprError();
2743
2744 // Explicit member accesses.
2745 } else {
2746 OwningExprResult Result =
2747 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002748 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002749
2750 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2751 Owned(Base);
2752 return ExprError();
2753 }
2754
2755 if (Result.get())
2756 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002757
2758 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2759 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760 }
2761
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002762 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002763 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2764 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765}
2766
2767Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002768Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2769 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2770 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002771 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002772 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002773 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2774 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002775 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002776 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002777 if (IsArrow) {
2778 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2779 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2780 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002781 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002782
2783 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2784 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2785 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2786 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2787
2788 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002789 return ExprError();
2790
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002791 if (R.empty()) {
2792 // Rederive where we looked up.
2793 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2794 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2795 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002796
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002797 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002798 << MemberName << DC
2799 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002800 return ExprError();
2801 }
2802
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002803 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2804 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2805 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2806 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2807 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2808 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2809 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2810 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2811 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2812 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002813 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002814 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002815 return ExprError();
2816
2817 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2818 // result.
2819 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002820 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002821 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002822 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002823 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002824
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002825 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2826 // pick a member.
2827 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2828
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002829 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2830 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2831 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002832 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2833 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002834 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2835 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002836 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837
2838 return Owned(MemExpr);
2839 }
2840
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002841 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002842 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002843 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2844
2845 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2846
2847 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2848 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2849 // error cases.
2850 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2851 return ExprError();
2852
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002853 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2854 if (!BaseExpr) {
2855 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002856 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002857 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2858
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002859 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2860 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2861 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2862 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002863 }
2864
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002865 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2866 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2867 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2868 // explicitly qualified.
2869 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2870 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2871 }
2872
2873 // Check the use of this member.
2874 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2875 Owned(BaseExpr);
2876 return ExprError();
2877 }
2878
2879 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2880 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2881 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002882 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2883 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002884 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2885 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2886
2887 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2888 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2889 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2890 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2891 else {
2892 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2893 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2894 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2895
2896 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2897 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2898
2899 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2900 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2901 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2902 }
2903
2904 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002905 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002906 return ExprError();
2907 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002908 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002909 }
2910
2911 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2912 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2913 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002914 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002915 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2916 }
2917
2918 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2919 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2920 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002921 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002922 MemberFn->getType()));
2923 }
2924
2925 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2926 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2927 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002928 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002929 }
2930
2931 Owned(BaseExpr);
2932
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002933 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002934 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002935 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2936 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2937 else
2938 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2939 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002941 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2942 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002943 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002944 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002945}
2946
2947/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2948/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2949/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2950/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2951/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2952/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2953/// an ordinary member expression.
2954///
2955/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2956/// fixed for ObjC++.
2957Sema::OwningExprResult
2958Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002959 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002960 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002961 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002962 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002963
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002964 // Perform default conversions.
2965 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002966
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002967 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002968 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2969
2970 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2971 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002972
2973 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002974 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002975 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2976 // call, and continue on.
2977 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2978 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2979 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2980 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2981 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002982 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2983 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002984 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2985 ->isRecordType()))) {
2986 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2987 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2988 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002989 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002990
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002991 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002992 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002993 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002994 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002995 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002996 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002997
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002998 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2999 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3000 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3001 }
3002 }
3003 }
3004
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003005 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3006 // use that.
3007 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003008 if (IsArrow) {
3009 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3010 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3011 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003012 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003013 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003014 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3015 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003016 }
3017 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003018 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3019 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3020 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3021 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003022 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003023 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003024 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003025
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003026 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3027 // use that.
3028 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3029 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3030 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3031 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3032 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
3033 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
3034 }
3035 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003036
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003037 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003038
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003039 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003040 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003041 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3042 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3043 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3044 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3045 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3046 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3047 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3048 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3049 // Check the use of this method.
3050 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3051 return ExprError();
3052 }
3053 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3054 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3055 Selector SetterSel =
3056 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3057 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3058 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3059 if (!Setter) {
3060 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3061 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003062 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003063 }
3064 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3065 if (!Setter)
3066 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003067
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003068 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3069 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003070
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003071 if (Getter || Setter) {
3072 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003073
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003074 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003075 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003076 else
3077 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3078 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3079 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003080 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003081 PType,
3082 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3083 }
3084 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3085 << MemberName << BaseType);
3086 }
3087 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003088
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003089 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3090 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3091 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003092 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003093 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003094
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003095 if (IsArrow) {
3096 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003097 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003098 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3099 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003100 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3101 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3102 // struct MyRecord foo;
3103 // foo->bar
3104 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3105 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3106 // by now.
3107 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3108 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003109 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003110 IsArrow = false;
3111 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003112 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3113 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3114 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003115 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003116 } else {
3117 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3118 // type *foo;
3119 // foo.bar
3120 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3121 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3122 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3123 // the appropriate pointer type
3124 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3125 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3126 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3127 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3128 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003129 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003130 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3131 IsArrow = true;
3132 }
3133 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003134 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003135
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003136 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003137 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003138 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003139 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003140 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003141 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003142 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003143
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003144 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3145 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003146 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003147 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003148 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003149 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3150 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3151 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3152 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003153 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3154
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003155 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003156 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003157
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003158 if (!IV) {
3159 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3160 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3161 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003162 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003163 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003164 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003165 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3166 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003167 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3168 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003169 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003170 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003171 } else {
3172 Res.clear();
3173 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003174 }
3175 }
3176
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003177 if (IV) {
3178 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3179 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3180 // error cases.
3181 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3182 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003183
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003184 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3185 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3186 return ExprError();
3187 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3188 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3189 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3190 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3191 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3192 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3193 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3194 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3195 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3196 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3197 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3198 // AST for a function decl.
3199 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003200 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003201 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3202 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3203 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3204 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3205 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3206 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003207
3208 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3209 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003210 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003211 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003212 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003213 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3214 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003215 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003216 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003217 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003218
3219 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3220 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003221 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003222 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003223 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003224 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003225 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003226 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003227 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003228 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003229 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3230 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003231 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003232 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003233
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003234 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003235 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003236 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3237 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3238 // Check the use of this declaration
3239 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3240 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003241
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003242 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3243 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3244 }
3245 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3246 // Check the use of this method.
3247 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3248 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003249
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003250 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003251 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003252 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3253 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003254 }
3255 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003256
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003257 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003258 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003259 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003260
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003261 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3262 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003263 if (!IsArrow)
3264 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3265 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003266 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003267
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003268 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003269 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003270 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3271 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003272 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003273 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003274 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003275
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003276 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003277 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003278 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003279 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3280 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003281 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003282 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003283 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003284 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003285
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003286 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3287 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3288
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003289 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003290}
3291
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003292/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3293/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3294/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3295/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3296/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3297///
3298/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3299/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3300/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3301/// only be called
3302/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3303/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3304/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3305Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3306 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3307 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003308 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003309 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3310 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3311 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3312 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3313 return ExprError();
3314
3315 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3316
3317 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3318 DeclarationName Name;
3319 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3320 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3321 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3322 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3323
3324 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3325
3326 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3327 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3328 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3329
3330 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3331 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3332
3333 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3334 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003335 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3336 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003337 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003338 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3339 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3340 Name, NameLoc,
3341 TemplateArgs);
3342 } else {
3343 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003344 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3345 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003346
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003347 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3348 Owned(Base);
3349 return ExprError();
3350 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003351
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003352 if (Result.get()) {
3353 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3354 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3355 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3356 // call now.
3357 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3358 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3359 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003360
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003361 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003362 }
3363
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003364 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003365 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3366 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003367 }
3368
3369 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003370}
3371
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003372Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3373 FunctionDecl *FD,
3374 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3375 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3376 Diag (CallLoc,
3377 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3378 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003379 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003380 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3381 } else {
3382 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3383 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3384
3385 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003386 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3387 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003388
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003389 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3390 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3391 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3392 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003393
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003394 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003395 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003396 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003397
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003398 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3399 InitializedEntity Entity
3400 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3401 InitializationKind Kind
3402 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3403 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3404 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3405
3406 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003407 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003408 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3409 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003410 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003411
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003412 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003413 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003414 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003415 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003416
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003417 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3418 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3419 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003420 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3421 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003422 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3423 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003424 }
3425
3426 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003427 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003428}
3429
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003430/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3431/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3432/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3433/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3434/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3435/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003436bool
3437Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003438 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003439 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003440 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3441 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003442 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003443 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3444 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003445 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003446
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003447 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3448 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3449 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3450 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3451 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003452 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003453 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003454 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003455 }
3456
3457 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3458 // them.
3459 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3460 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3461 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3462 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003463 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003464 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003465 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3466 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3467 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003468 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003469 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003470 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003471 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003472 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003473 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003474 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3475 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3476 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3477 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3478 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003479 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003480 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003481 if (Invalid)
3482 return true;
3483 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3484 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3485 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003486
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003487 return false;
3488}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003489
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003490bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3491 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3492 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3493 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3494 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3495 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003496 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003497 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3498 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3499 bool Invalid = false;
3500 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3501 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3502 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3503 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003504 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003505 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003506 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003507
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003508 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003509 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3510 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003511
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003512 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3513 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003514 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003515 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003516 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003517
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003518 // Pass the argument
3519 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3520 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3521 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003522
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003523
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003524 InitializedEntity Entity =
3525 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3526 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3527 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3528 SourceLocation(),
3529 Owned(Arg));
3530 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3531 return true;
3532
3533 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003534 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003535 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003536
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003537 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003538 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003539 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3540 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003541
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003542 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003543 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003544 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003545 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003546
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003547 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003548 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003549 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003550 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003551 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003552 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003553 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003554 }
3555 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003556 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003557}
3558
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003559/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003560/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3561/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003562Action::OwningExprResult
3563Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3564 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003565 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003566 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003567
3568 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3569 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003570
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003571 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003572 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003573 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003574
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003575 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003576 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3577 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3578 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3579 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3580 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003581 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003582 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3583 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003584
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003585 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3586 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003587
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003588 NumArgs = 0;
3589 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003590
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003591 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3592 RParenLoc));
3593 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003594
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003595 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003596 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003597 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3598 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003599 bool Dependent = false;
3600 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3601 Dependent = true;
3602 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3603 Dependent = true;
3604
3605 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003606 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003607 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3608
3609 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3610 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3611 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3612 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3613
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003614 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3615
3616 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3617 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3618 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3619 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3620 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3621 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3622 // method template.
3623 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003624 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3625 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003626 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003627
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003628 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3629 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003630 }
3631
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003632 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003633 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003634 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003635 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003636 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3637 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003638 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003639
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003640 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003641 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003642 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3643 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003644 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3645 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003646 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003647
3648 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3649 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003650 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3651 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003652
3653 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3654 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003655 TheCall.get(), 0))
3656 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003657
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003658 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003659 RParenLoc))
3660 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003661
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003662 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3663 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003664 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003665 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3666 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003667 }
3668 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003669 }
3670
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003671 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003672 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003673 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003674
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003675 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003676 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3677 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003678 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003679 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003680 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003681
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003682 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3683 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3684 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3685
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003686 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3687}
3688
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003689/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3690/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003691/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3692/// block-pointer type.
3693///
3694/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3695Sema::OwningExprResult
3696Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3697 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3698 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3699 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3700 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3701
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003702 // Promote the function operand.
3703 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3704
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003705 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3706 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003707 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3708 Args, NumArgs,
3709 Context.BoolTy,
3710 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003711
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003712 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3713 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3714 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3715 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003716 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003717 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003718 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3719 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003720 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003721 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003722 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003723 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003724 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003725 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003726 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3727 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3728
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003729 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003730 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003731 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3732 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003733 return ExprError();
3734
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003735 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003736 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003737
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003738 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003739 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003740 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003741 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003742 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003743 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003744
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003745 if (FDecl) {
3746 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3747 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3748 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003749 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003750 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003751 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003752 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3753 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3754 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3755 }
3756 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003757 }
3758
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003759 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003760 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3761 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3762 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003763 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3764 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003765 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3766 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003767 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003768 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003769 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003770 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003771
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003772 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3773 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003774 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3775 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003776
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003777 // Check for sentinels
3778 if (NDecl)
3779 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003780
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003781 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003782 if (FDecl) {
3783 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3784 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003785
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003786 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003787 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3788 } else if (NDecl) {
3789 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3790 return ExprError();
3791 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003792
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003793 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003794}
3795
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003796Action::OwningExprResult
3797Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3798 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003799 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003800 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003801 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003802
3803 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3804 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3805 if (!TInfo)
3806 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3807
3808 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3809}
3810
3811Action::OwningExprResult
3812Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3813 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3814 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003815 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003816
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003817 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003818 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003819 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3820 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003821 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3822 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003823 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003824 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003825 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003826 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003827
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003828 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003829 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003830 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003831 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003832 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003833 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3834 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3835 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3836 &literalType);
3837 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003838 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003839 InitExpr.release();
3840 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003841
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003842 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003843 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003844 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003845 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003846 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003847
3848 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003849
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003850 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003851 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003852}
3853
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003854Action::OwningExprResult
3855Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003856 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3857 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3858 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003859
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003860 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003861 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003862
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003863 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3864 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003865 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003866 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003867}
3868
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003869static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3870 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003871 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003872 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3873
3874 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3875 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003876 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3877 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003878 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003879 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3880 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3881 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003882
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003883 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3884 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3885 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3886 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3887 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3888 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3889 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3890 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003891
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003892 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3893 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3894 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3895 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3896 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3897 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003898
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003899 // FIXME: Assert here.
3900 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3901 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3902}
3903
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003904/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003905bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003906 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003907 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003908 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003909 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003910 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3911 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003912
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003913 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003914
3915 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3916 // type needs to be scalar.
3917 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3918 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003919 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3920 return false;
3921 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003922
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003923 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3924 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3925 return true;
3926
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003927 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003928 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003929 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3930 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003931 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003932 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3933 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003934 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003935 return false;
3936 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003937
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003938 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003939 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003940 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003941 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003942 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003943 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003944 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003945 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003946 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3947 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3948 break;
3949 }
3950 }
3951 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3952 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3953 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003954 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003955 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003956 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003957
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003958 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3959 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3960 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3961 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003962
3963 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003964 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003965 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3966 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003967 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003968 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003969
3970 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003971 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003972
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003973 if (castType->isVectorType())
3974 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3975 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3976 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3977
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003978 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3979 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003980
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003981 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003982 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003983 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003984 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003985 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3986 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3987 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3988 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003989 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003990 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3991 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3992 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003993 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003994
3995 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003996 return false;
3997}
3998
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003999bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
4000 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004001 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004002
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004003 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004004 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004005 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004006 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004007 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004008 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004009 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004010 } else
4011 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004012 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004013 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004014
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004015 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004016 return false;
4017}
4018
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004019bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004020 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004021 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004022
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004023 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004024
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004025 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4026 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004027 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4028 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4029 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4030 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004031 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004032 return false;
4033 }
4034
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004035 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004036 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4037 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004038 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4039 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4040 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4041 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004042
4043 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4044 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4045 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004046
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004047 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004048 return false;
4049}
4050
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004051Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004052Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004053 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4054 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4055 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004056
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004057 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4058 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4059 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004060 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004061
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004062 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004063 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004064 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004065 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4066 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004067
4068 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4069}
4070
4071Action::OwningExprResult
4072Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4073 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4074 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4075
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004076 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004077 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004078 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004079 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004080 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004081
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004082 Op.release();
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004083 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(
4084 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004085 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004086 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004087}
4088
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004089/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4090/// of comma binary operators.
4091Action::OwningExprResult
4092Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4093 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4094 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4095 if (!E)
4096 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004097
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004098 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004100 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4101 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4102 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004103
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004104 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4105}
4106
4107Action::OwningExprResult
4108Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4109 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004110 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004111 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004112 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004113 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004114
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004115 // Check for an altivec literal,
4116 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004117 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4118 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4119 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4120 return ExprError();
4121 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004122 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4123 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4124 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4125 }
4126 else
4127 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4128 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004129
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004130 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4131 // then handle it as such.
4132 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004133 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4134 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4135 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4136
4137 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4138 // braces instead of the original commas.
4139 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004140 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4141 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004142 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4143 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004144 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004145 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004146 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004147 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4148 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004149 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004150 }
4151}
4152
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004153Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004154 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004155 MultiExprArg Val,
4156 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004157 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4158 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004159 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4160 Expr *expr;
4161 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4162 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4163 else
4164 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004165 return Owned(expr);
4166}
4167
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004168/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4169/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004170/// C99 6.5.15
4171QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4172 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004173 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4174 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4175 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4176
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004177 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4178 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4179 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4180 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4181 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4182 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004183
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004184 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004185 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4186 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4187 << CondTy;
4188 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004189 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004190
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004191 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004192 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4193 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004194
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004195 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4196 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004197 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4198 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4199 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004200 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004201
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004202 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4203 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004204 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4205 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004206 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004207 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004208 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004209 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004210 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004211 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004212
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004213 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004214 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004215 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4216 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4217 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4218 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4219 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4220 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4221 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004222 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4223 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004224 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004225 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004226 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4227 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004228 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004229 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004230 // promote the null to a pointer.
4231 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004232 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004233 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004234 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004235 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004236 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004237 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004238 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004239
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004240 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4241 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4242 QuestionLoc);
4243 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4244 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004245
4246
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004247 // Handle block pointer types.
4248 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4249 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4250 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4251 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004252 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4253 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004254 return destType;
4255 }
4256 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004257 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004258 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004259 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004260 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4261 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4262 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004263 return LHSTy;
4264 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004265 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004266 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4267 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004268
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004269 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4270 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004271 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004272 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004273 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4274 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4275 // to get a consistent AST.
4276 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004277 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4278 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004279 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004280 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004281 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004282 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4283 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004284 return LHSTy;
4285 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004286
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004287 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4288 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4289 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004290 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4291 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004292
4293 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4294 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4295 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004296 QualType destPointee
4297 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004298 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004299 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4300 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4301 // Promote to void*.
4302 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004303 return destType;
4304 }
4305 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004306 QualType destPointee
4307 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004308 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004309 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004310 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004311 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004312 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004313 return destType;
4314 }
4315
4316 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4317 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4318 return LHSTy;
4319 }
4320 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4321 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4322 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4323 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4324 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4325 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4326 // to get a consistent AST.
4327 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004328 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4329 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004330 return incompatTy;
4331 }
4332 // The pointer types are compatible.
4333 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4334 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4335 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4336 // type.
4337 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4338 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004339 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4340 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004341 return LHSTy;
4342 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004343
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004344 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4345 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4346 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4347 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004348 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004349 return RHSTy;
4350 }
4351 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4352 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4353 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004354 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004355 return LHSTy;
4356 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004357
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004358 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004359 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4360 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004361 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004362}
4363
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004364/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4365/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4366QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4367 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4368 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4369 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004370
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004371 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4372 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4373 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4374 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4375 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4376 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4377 return LHSTy;
4378 }
4379 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4380 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4381 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4382 return RHSTy;
4383 }
4384 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4385 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4386 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4387 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4388 return LHSTy;
4389 }
4390 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4391 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4392 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4393 return RHSTy;
4394 }
4395 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4396 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4397 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4398 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4399 return LHSTy;
4400 }
4401 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4402 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4403 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4404 return RHSTy;
4405 }
4406 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4407 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004408
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004409 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4410 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4411 return LHSTy;
4412 }
4413 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4414 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4415 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004416
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004417 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4418 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4419 // type. This allows
4420 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4421 // where B is a subclass of A.
4422 //
4423 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4424 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4425 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4426 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004427
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004428 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4429 // It could return the composite type.
4430 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4431 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4432 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4433 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4434 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4435 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4436 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4437 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4438 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4439 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4440 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4441 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4442 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4443 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004444 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004445 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4446 ;
4447 else {
4448 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4449 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4450 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4451 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4452 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4453 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4454 return incompatTy;
4455 }
4456 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4457 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4458 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4459 return compositeType;
4460 }
4461 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4462 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4463 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4464 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4465 QualType destPointee
4466 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4467 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4468 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4469 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4470 // Promote to void*.
4471 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4472 return destType;
4473 }
4474 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4475 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4476 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4477 QualType destPointee
4478 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4479 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4480 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4481 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4482 // Promote to void*.
4483 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4484 return destType;
4485 }
4486 return QualType();
4487}
4488
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004489/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004490/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004491Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4492 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4493 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4494 ExprArg RHS) {
4495 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4496 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004497
4498 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4499 // was the condition.
4500 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4501 if (isLHSNull)
4502 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004503
4504 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004505 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004506 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004507 return ExprError();
4508
4509 Cond.release();
4510 LHS.release();
4511 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004512 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004513 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004514 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004515}
4516
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004517// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004518// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004519// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4520// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4521// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004522Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004523Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004524 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004525
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004526 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4527 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4528 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4529 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4530 return Compatible;
4531 }
4532
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004533 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004534 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4535 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004536
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004537 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004538 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4539 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004540
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004541 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004542
4543 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4544 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4545 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004546 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004547 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004548 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004549
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004550 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4551 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004552 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004553 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004554 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004555 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004556
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004557 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004558 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4559 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004560 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004561
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004562 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004563 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004564 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004565
4566 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004567 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4568 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004569 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004570 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004571 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004572 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4573 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4574 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4575 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4576 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4577 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004578 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004579 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004580 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004581 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004582
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004583 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004584 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004585 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004586 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004587
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004588 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4589 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4590 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4591 // warning can be disabled.
4592 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4593 return ConvTy;
4594 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4595 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004596
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004597 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4598 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4599 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4600 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4601 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4602 do {
4603 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4604 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004605
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004606 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4607 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4608 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004609
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004610 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004611 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004612 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004613
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004614 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004615 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004616 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004617 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004618}
4619
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004620/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4621/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4622/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4623// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004624Sema::AssignConvertType
4625Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004626 QualType rhsType) {
4627 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004628
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004629 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004630 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4631 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004633 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4634 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4635 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004636
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004637 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004639 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004640 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004641 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004642
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004643 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4644 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4645 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4646 }
4647 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004648 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004649 return ConvTy;
4650}
4651
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004652/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4653/// for assignment compatibility.
4654Sema::AssignConvertType
4655Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004656 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4657 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004658 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4659 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004660 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004661 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004662 }
4663 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4664 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004665 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4666 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004667 return IncompatiblePointer;
4668 return Compatible;
4669 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004670 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004671 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004672 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004673 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4674 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4675 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4676 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4677 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4678 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004679
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004680 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4681 return Compatible;
4682 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4683 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004684 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004685}
4686
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004687/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4688/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004689/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4690///
4691/// int a, *pint;
4692/// short *pshort;
4693/// struct foo *pfoo;
4694///
4695/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4696/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4697/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4698/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4699///
4700/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004701/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004702///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004703Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004704Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004705 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4706 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004707 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4708 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004709
4710 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004711 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004712
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004713 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4714 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4715 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4716 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4717 return Compatible;
4718 }
4719
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004720 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4721 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4722 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4723 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4724 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4725 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4726 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004727 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004728 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004729 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004730 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004731 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004732 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4733 // to the same ExtVector type.
4734 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4735 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4736 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004737 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004738 return Compatible;
4739 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004740
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004741 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004742 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004743 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004744 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004745 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4746 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004747 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004748 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004749 }
4750 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004751 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004752
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004753 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4754 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004755 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004756
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004757 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004758 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004759 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004760
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004761 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004762 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004763
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004764 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004765 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004766 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4767 return Compatible;
4768 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004769 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004770 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4771 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004772 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004773
4774 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004775 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004776 return Compatible;
4777 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004778 return Incompatible;
4779 }
4780
4781 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4782 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004783 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004784
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004785 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004786 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004787 return Compatible;
4788
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004789 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4790 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004791
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004792 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004793 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004794 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004795 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004796 return Incompatible;
4797 }
4798
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004799 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4800 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4801 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004802
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004803 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004804 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004805 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4806 return Compatible;
4807 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004808 }
4809 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004810 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004811 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004812 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004813 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4814 return Compatible;
4815 }
4816 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4817 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4818 return Compatible;
4819 return Incompatible;
4820 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004821 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004822 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004823 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4824 return Compatible;
4825
4826 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004827 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004828
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004829 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004830 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004831
4832 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004833 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004834 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004835 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004836 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004837 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4838 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4839 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4840 return Compatible;
4841
4842 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4843 return PointerToInt;
4844
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004845 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004846 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004847 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4848 return Compatible;
4849 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004850 }
4851 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004852 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004853 return Compatible;
4854 return Incompatible;
4855 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004856
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004857 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004858 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004859 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004860 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004861 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004862}
4863
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004864/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4865/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004866static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004867 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4868 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4869 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004870 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004871 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004872 SourceLocation());
4873 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4874 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4875
4876 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4877 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004878 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004879 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004880 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004881}
4882
4883Sema::AssignConvertType
4884Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4885 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4886
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004887 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004888 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4889 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004890 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004891 return Incompatible;
4892
4893 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4894 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4895 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4896 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004897 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4898 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004899 it != itend; ++it) {
4900 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4901 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4902 // 1) void pointer
4903 // 2) null pointer constant
4904 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004905 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004906 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004907 InitField = *it;
4908 break;
4909 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004910
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004911 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004912 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004913 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004914 InitField = *it;
4915 break;
4916 }
4917 }
4918
4919 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4920 == Compatible) {
4921 InitField = *it;
4922 break;
4923 }
4924 }
4925
4926 if (!InitField)
4927 return Incompatible;
4928
4929 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4930 return Compatible;
4931}
4932
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004933Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004934Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004935 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4936 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4937 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4938 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4939 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004940 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004941 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004942 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004943 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004944 }
4945
4946 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4947 // structures.
4948 }
4949
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004950 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4951 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004952 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4953 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004954 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004955 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004956 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004957 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004958 return Compatible;
4959 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004960
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004961 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004962 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004963 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004964 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004965 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004966 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004967 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004968 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004969
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004970 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4971 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004972
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004973 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4974 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004975 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4976 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4977 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4978 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004979 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004980 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004981 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004982 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004983}
4984
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004985QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004986 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004987 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004988 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004989 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004990}
4991
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004992QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004993 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004994 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004995 QualType lhsType =
4996 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4997 QualType rhsType =
4998 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004999
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005000 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005001 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005002 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005003
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005004 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5005 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005006 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5007 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005008 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5009 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005010 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005011 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005012 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5013 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5014 return lhsType;
5015 }
5016
5017 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5018 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005019 }
5020 }
5021 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005022
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005023 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5024 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5025 bool swapped = false;
5026 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5027 swapped = true;
5028 std::swap(rex, lex);
5029 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5030 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005031
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005032 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005033 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005034 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005035 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005036 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005037 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005038 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5039 return lhsType;
5040 }
5041 }
5042 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5043 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5044 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005045 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005046 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5047 return lhsType;
5048 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005049 }
5050 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005051
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005052 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005053 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005054 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005055 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005056 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005057}
5058
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005059QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5060 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005061 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005062 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005063
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005064 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005065
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005066 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5067 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5068 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005069
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005070 // Check for division by zero.
5071 if (isDiv &&
5072 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005073 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005074 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005075
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005076 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005077}
5078
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005079QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005080 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005081 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005082 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5083 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005084 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5085 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5086 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005087
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005088 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005089
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005090 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5091 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005092
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005093 // Check for remainder by zero.
5094 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005095 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5096 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005097
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005098 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005099}
5100
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005101QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005102 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005103 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5104 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5105 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5106 return compType;
5107 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005108
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005109 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005110
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005111 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005112 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5113 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5114 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005115 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005116 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005117
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005118 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5119 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005120 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005121 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5122
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005123 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005124
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005125 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005126 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005127
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005128 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5129 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005130 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5131 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005132 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005133 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005134 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005135
5136 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5137 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5138 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005139 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005140 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5141 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5142 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5143 return QualType();
5144 }
5145
5146 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5147 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5148 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005149 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005150 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005151 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005152 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005153 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5154 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005155 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5156 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005157 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005158 return QualType();
5159 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005160 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005161 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005162 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5163 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5164 return QualType();
5165 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005166
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005167 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005168 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5169 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5170 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5171 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5172 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005173 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005174 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5175 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005176 return PExp->getType();
5177 }
5178 }
5179
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005180 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005181}
5182
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005183// C99 6.5.6
5184QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005185 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5186 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5187 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5188 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5189 return compType;
5190 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005191
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005192 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005193
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005194 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005195
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005196 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005197 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5198 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005199 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005200 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005201 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005202
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005203 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005204 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005205 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005206
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005207 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005208
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005209 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5210 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5211 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5212 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5213 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5214 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5215 return QualType();
5216 }
5217
5218 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5219 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5220 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5221 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5222 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005223 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005224 return QualType();
5225 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005226
5227 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5228 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5229 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005230 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005231 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005232 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005233 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005234 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005235
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005236 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005237 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005238 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5239 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5240 return QualType();
5241 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005242
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005243 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005244 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5245 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5246 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5247 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5248 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5249 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005250 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005251 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5252
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005253 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005254 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005255 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005256
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005257 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005258 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005259 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005260
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005261 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5262 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5263 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5264 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5265 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5266 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5267 return QualType();
5268 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005269
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005270 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5271 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5272 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5273 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005274 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005275 return QualType();
5276 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005277
5278 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5279 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5280 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5281 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5282 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005283 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5284 << rex->getSourceRange()
5285 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005286 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005287
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005288 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5289 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5290 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5291 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5292 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5293 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5294 return QualType();
5295 }
5296 } else {
5297 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5298 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5299 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5300 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5301 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5302 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5303 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5304 return QualType();
5305 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005306 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005307
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005308 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5309 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5310 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5311 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5312 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005313 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005314 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005315
5316 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005317 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5318 }
5319 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005320
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005321 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005322}
5323
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005324// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005325QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005326 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005327 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005328 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5329 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005330 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005331
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005332 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5333 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5334 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5335
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005336 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5337 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005338 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5339 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5340 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5341 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5342 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005343 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005344 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005345 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005346
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005347 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005348
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005349 // Sanity-check shift operands
5350 llvm::APSInt Right;
5351 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005352 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5353 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005354 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005355 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5356 else {
5357 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5358 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5359 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5360 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5361 }
5362 }
5363
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005364 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005365 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005366}
5367
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005368static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5369 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5370 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5371 return true;
5372 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5373 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5374 }
5375 return false;
5376}
5377
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005378// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005379QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005380 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5381 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5382
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005383 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005384 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005385 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005386
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005387 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5388 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005389
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005390 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5391 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005392 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5393 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5394 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005395 //
5396 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5397 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5398 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5399 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5400 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5401 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005402 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5403 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005404 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005405 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005406 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005407 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005408 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5409 << 0 // self-
5410 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5411 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5412 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5413 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5414 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5415 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5416 // what is it always going to eval to?
5417 char always_evals_to;
5418 switch(Opc) {
5419 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5420 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5421 break;
5422 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5423 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5424 break;
5425 default:
5426 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5427 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5428 break;
5429 }
5430 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5431 << 1 // array
5432 << always_evals_to);
5433 }
5434 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005435 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005436
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005437 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5438 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5439 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5440 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005441
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005442 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5443 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005444 Expr *literalString = 0;
5445 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005446 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005447 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005448 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005449 literalString = lex;
5450 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005451 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5452 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005453 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005454 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005455 literalString = rex;
5456 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5457 }
5458
5459 if (literalString) {
5460 std::string resultComparison;
5461 switch (Opc) {
5462 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5463 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5464 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5465 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5466 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5467 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5468 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5469 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005470
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005471 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5472 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5473 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005474 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005475 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005476 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005477
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005478 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5479 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5480 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5481 else {
5482 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5483 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5484 }
5485
5486 lType = lex->getType();
5487 rType = rex->getType();
5488
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005489 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005490 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005491
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005492 if (isRelational) {
5493 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005494 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005495 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005496 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005497 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005498 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005499
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005500 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005501 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005502 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005503
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005504 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005505 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005506 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005507 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005508
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005509 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5510 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005511 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005512 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005513 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005514 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005515 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005516
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005517 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005518 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5519 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005520 if (!isRelational &&
5521 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5522 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5523 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005524 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5525 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005526 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5527 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005528 Diag(Loc,
5529 isSFINAEContext()?
5530 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5531 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005532 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005533
5534 if (isSFINAEContext())
5535 return QualType();
5536
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005537 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5538 return ResultTy;
5539 }
5540 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005541 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5542 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5543 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5544 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5545 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5546 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005547 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005548 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005549 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005550 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005551 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005552 if (T.isNull()) {
5553 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5554 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5555 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005556 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005557 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005558 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005559 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005560 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005561 }
5562
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005563 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5564 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005565 return ResultTy;
5566 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005567 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5568 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5569 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5570 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5571 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5572 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5573 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5574 }
5575 } else if (!isRelational &&
5576 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5577 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5578 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5579 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5580 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5581 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5582 }
5583 } else {
5584 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005585 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005586 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005587 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005588 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005589 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005590 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005591 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005592
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005593 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005594 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005595 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005596 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005597 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5598 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005599 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005600 return ResultTy;
5601 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005602 if (LHSIsNull &&
5603 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5604 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005605 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005606 return ResultTy;
5607 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005608
5609 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005610 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005611 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5612 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005613 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5614 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5615 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5616 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5617 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5618 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5619 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5620 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005621 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005622 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005623 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005624 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005625 if (T.isNull()) {
5626 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005627 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005628 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005629 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005630 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005631 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005632 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005633 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005634 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005635
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005636 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5637 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005638 return ResultTy;
5639 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005640
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005641 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005642 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5643 return ResultTy;
5644 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005645
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005646 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005647 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005648 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5649 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005650
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005651 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005652 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005653 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005654 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005655 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005656 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005657 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005658 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005659 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005660 if (!isRelational
5661 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5662 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005663 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005664 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005665 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005666 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005667 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5668 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5669 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005670 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005671 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005672 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005673 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005674
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005675 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005676 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005677 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5678 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005679 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005680 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005681 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005682 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005683
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005684 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5685 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005686 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005687 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005688 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005689 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005690 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005691 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005692 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005693 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005694 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5695 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005696 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005697 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005698 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005699 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005700 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5701 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005702 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005703 bool isError = false;
5704 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5705 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5706 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005707 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005708 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005709 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005710 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5711 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5712 isError = true;
5713 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005714 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005715
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005716 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005717 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005718 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005719 if (isError)
5720 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005721 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005722
5723 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5724 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005725 else
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005726 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005727 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005728 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005729
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005730 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005731 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5732 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005733 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005734 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005735 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005736 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5737 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005738 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005739 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005740 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005741 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005742}
5743
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005744/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005745/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005746/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5747/// types.
5748QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005749 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005750 bool isRelational) {
5751 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5752 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005753 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005754 if (vType.isNull())
5755 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005756
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005757 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5758 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005759
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005760 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5761 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5762 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005763 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005764 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5765 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5766 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005767 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5768 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5769 << 0 // self-
5770 << 2 // "a constant"
5771 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005772 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005773
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005774 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005775 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5776 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005777 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005778 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005779
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005780 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5781 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5782 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005783 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005784 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005785
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005786 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005787 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005788 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005789 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005790 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005791 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5792
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005793 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005794 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005795 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5796}
5797
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005798inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005799 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005800 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5801 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5802 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5803 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5804
5805 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5806 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005807
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005808 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005809
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005810 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005811 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005812 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005813}
5814
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005815inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005816 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5817
5818 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5819 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5820 // is a constant.
5821 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
5822 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->isEvaluatable(Context) &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005823 // Don't warn if the RHS is a (constant folded) boolean expression like
5824 // "sizeof(int) == 4".
5825 !rex->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue() &&
5826 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005827 !Loc.isMacroID())
5828 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5829 << rex->getSourceRange()
5830 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5831 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&" : "|");
5832
5833
5834
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005835 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5836 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5837 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005838
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005839 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5840 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005841
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005842 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005843 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005844
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005845 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5846 // non-overloadable operands.
5847
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005848 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5849 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005850 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5851 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5852 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005853 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005854
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005855 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5856 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5857 // The result is a bool.
5858 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005859}
5860
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005861/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5862/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5863/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5864///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005865static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005866 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5867 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5868 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5869 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005870 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005871 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5872 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5873 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5874 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005875 }
5876 }
5877 return false;
5878}
5879
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005880/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5881/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5882static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005883 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005884 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005885 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005886 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5887 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005888 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5889 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005890
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005891 unsigned Diag = 0;
5892 bool NeedType = false;
5893 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005894 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005895 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005896 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5897 NeedType = true;
5898 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005899 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005900 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5901 NeedType = true;
5902 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005903 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005904 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5905 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005906 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5907 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005908 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005909 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5910 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005911 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5912 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005913 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5914 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005915 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005916 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005917 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005918 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005919 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5920 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005921 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005922 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5923 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005924 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5925 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5926 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005927 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5928 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5929 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005930 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5931 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5932 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005933 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005934
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005935 SourceRange Assign;
5936 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5937 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005938 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005939 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005940 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005941 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005942 return true;
5943}
5944
5945
5946
5947// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005948QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5949 SourceLocation Loc,
5950 QualType CompoundType) {
5951 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5952 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005953 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005954
5955 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5956 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005957 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005958 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005959 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005960 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005961 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5962 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5963 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5964 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5965 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5966 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5967 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5968 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5969 }
5970 }
5971
5972 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005973 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5974 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5975 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005976 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005977 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005978 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005979 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005980
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005981 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5982 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5983 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005984 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005985 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5986 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5987 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5988 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5989 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005990 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005991 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005992 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5993 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5994 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005995 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5996 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005997 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5998 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5999 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006000 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006001 }
6002 } else {
6003 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006004 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006005 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006006
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006007 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006008 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006009 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006010
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006011
6012 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6013 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6014 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6015 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6016 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6017 // check.
6018 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
6019 if (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref &&
6020 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6021 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6022 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6023 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6024 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6025 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6026 }
6027
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006028 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6029 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006030 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006031 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6032 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006033 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006034 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006035 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006036}
6037
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006038// C99 6.5.17
6039QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006040 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6041
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006042 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006043 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6044 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6045 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006046
6047 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6048 // incomplete in C++).
6049
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006050 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006051}
6052
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006053/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6054/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006055QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006056 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006057 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6058 return Context.DependentTy;
6059
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006060 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6061 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006062
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006063 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6064 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6065 if (!isInc) {
6066 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6067 return QualType();
6068 }
6069 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6070 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6071 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006072 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006073 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6074 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006075
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006076 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006077 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006078 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6079 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6080 << Op->getSourceRange();
6081 return QualType();
6082 }
6083
6084 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006085 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006086 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006087 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6088 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6089 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6090 return QualType();
6091 }
6092
6093 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006094 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006095 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006096 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006097 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006098 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006099 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006100 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006101 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006102 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6103 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6104 return QualType();
6105 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006106 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006107 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6108 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006109 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006110 } else {
6111 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006112 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006113 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006114 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006115 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006116 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006117 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006118 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006119 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6120 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6121 // operand.
6122 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6123 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006124}
6125
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006126/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006127/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006128/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6129/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6130/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6131/// - &(x) => x
6132/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6133/// - &s.xx => s
6134/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6135/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6136/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6137/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006138static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006139 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006140 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006141 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006142 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006143 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6144 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6145 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006146 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006147 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006148 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006149 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006150 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006151 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6152 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006153 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6154 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6155 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6156 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6157 }
6158 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006159 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006160 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6161 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006162
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006163 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006164 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6165 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6166 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6167 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6168 default:
6169 return 0;
6170 }
6171 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006172 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006173 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006174 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006175 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6176 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006177 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006178 default:
6179 return 0;
6180 }
6181}
6182
6183/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006184/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006185/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006186/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006187/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006188/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006189/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006190QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006191 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6192 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6193
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006194 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6195 return Context.DependentTy;
6196
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006197 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6198 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6199 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6200 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6201 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6202 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6203 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6204 }
6205 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6206 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6207 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006208 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006209 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006210
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006211 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6212 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6213 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6214 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6215 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6216 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6217 // branch of the if, below.
6218 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6219 << dcl;
6220 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6221
6222 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6223 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6224 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6225 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006226 }
6227
6228 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006229 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6230 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6231 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6232 if (isSFINAEContext())
6233 return QualType();
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006234 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006235 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006236 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006237 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006238 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006239 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006240 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006241 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6242 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006243 return QualType();
6244 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006245 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006246 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6247 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6248 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006249 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006250 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006251 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006252 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006253 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006254 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006255 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6256 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6257 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6258 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6259 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006260 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6261 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006262 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6263 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006264 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6265 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006266 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006267 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006268 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6269 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006270 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006271 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6272 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006273 return QualType();
6274 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006275 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006276 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006277 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006278 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006279 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6280 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006281 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006282 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006283 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6284 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006285 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006286 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6287 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6288 return QualType();
6289 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006290
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006291 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6292 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006293 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006294 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006295 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006296 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006297 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006298 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6299 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006300 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6301 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6302 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006303 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006304 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006305
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006306 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6307 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6308 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6309 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6310 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6311 }
6312
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006313 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006314 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006315}
6316
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006317/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006318QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006319 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6320 return Context.DependentTy;
6321
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006322 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006323 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6324 QualType Result;
6325
6326 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6327 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6328 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6329 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6330 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6331 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6332 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6333 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6334 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006335
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006336 if (Result.isNull()) {
6337 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6338 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6339 return QualType();
6340 }
6341
6342 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006343}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006344
6345static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6346 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6347 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6348 switch (Kind) {
6349 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006350 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6351 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006352 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6353 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6354 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6355 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6356 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6357 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6358 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6359 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6360 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6361 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6362 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6363 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6364 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6365 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6366 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6367 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6368 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6369 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6370 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6371 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6372 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6373 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6374 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6375 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6376 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6377 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6378 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6379 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6380 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6381 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6382 }
6383 return Opc;
6384}
6385
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006386static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6387 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6388 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6389 switch (Kind) {
6390 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6391 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6392 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6393 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6394 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6395 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6396 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6397 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6398 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006399 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6400 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006401 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006402 }
6403 return Opc;
6404}
6405
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006406/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6407/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6408/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006409Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6410 unsigned Op,
6411 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006412 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006413 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006414 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6415 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6416 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006417
6418 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006419 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6420 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6421 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006422 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6423 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6424 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6425 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6426 break;
6427 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006428 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006429 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6430 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006431 break;
6432 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6433 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6434 break;
6435 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6436 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6437 break;
6438 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6439 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6440 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006441 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006442 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6443 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6444 break;
6445 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6446 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6447 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6448 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006449 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006450 break;
6451 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6452 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006453 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006454 break;
6455 case BinaryOperator::And:
6456 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6457 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6458 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6459 break;
6460 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6461 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006462 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006463 break;
6464 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6465 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006466 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6467 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006468 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6469 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6470 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006471 break;
6472 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006473 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6474 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6475 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6476 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006477 break;
6478 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006479 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6480 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6481 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006482 break;
6483 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006484 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6485 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6486 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006487 break;
6488 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6489 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006490 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6491 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6492 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6493 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006494 break;
6495 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6496 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6497 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006498 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6499 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6500 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6501 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006502 break;
6503 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6504 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6505 break;
6506 }
6507 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006508 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006509 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006510 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6511 else
6512 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006513 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6514 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006515}
6516
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006517/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6518/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006519static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6520 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006521 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6522 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6523 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006524 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006525 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6526
6527 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6528 return;
6529
6530 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6531 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6532 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006533 return;
6534 }
6535
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006536 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6537 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006538 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006539
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006540 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006541 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006542
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006543 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6544 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6545 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6546 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006547 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006548 return;
6549 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006550
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006551 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006552 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6553 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006554}
6555
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006556/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6557/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6558/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6559/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006560static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6561 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006562 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6563 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6564 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6565 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006566 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006567 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006568 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6569
6570 // Subs are not binary operators.
6571 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6572 return;
6573
6574 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6575 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006576 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6577 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006578 return;
6579
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006580 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006581 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006582 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006583 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6584 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006585 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006586 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006587 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6588 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6589 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6590 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006591 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006592 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006593 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006594 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6595 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006596 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006597 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006598 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6599 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6600 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6601 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006602}
6603
6604/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6605/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6606/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6607static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6608 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006609 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006610 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6611}
6612
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006613// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006614Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6615 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6616 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006617 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006618 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006619
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006620 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6621 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006622
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006623 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6624 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6625
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006626 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6627}
6628
6629Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6630 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6631 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006632 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006633 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006634 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6635 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6636 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6637 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6638 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006639 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006640 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006641 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6642 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6643 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006644
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006645 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6646 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006647 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006648 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006649
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006650 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006651 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006652}
6653
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006654Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006655 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006656 ExprArg InputArg) {
6657 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006658
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006659 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006660 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006661 QualType resultType;
6662 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006663 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6664 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6665 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006666
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006667 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6668 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006669 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6670 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006671 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006672 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006673 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6674 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6675 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006676 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006677 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006678 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006679 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006680 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006681 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006682 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006683 break;
6684 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6685 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006686 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6687 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006688 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6689 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006690 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6691 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006692 break;
6693 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6694 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6695 break;
6696 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6697 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6698 resultType->isPointerType())
6699 break;
6700
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006701 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6702 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006703 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006704 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6705 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006706 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6707 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006708 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6709 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6710 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006711 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006712 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006713 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006714 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6715 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006716 break;
6717 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006718 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006719 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006720 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006721 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6722 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006723 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006724 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6725 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006726 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006727 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6728 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006729 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006730 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006731 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006732 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006733 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006734 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006735 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006736 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006737 }
6738 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006739 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006740
6741 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006742 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006743}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006744
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006745Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6746 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6747 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006748 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006749 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6750 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006751 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6752 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6753 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6754 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006755 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006756 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006757 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6758 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6759 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006760
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006761 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6762 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006763
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006764 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6765}
6766
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006767// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6768Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6769 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6770 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6771}
6772
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006773/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006774Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6775 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6776 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006777 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006778 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006779
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006780 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6781 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006782 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006783 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006784
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006785 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006786 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6787 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006788}
6789
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006790Sema::OwningExprResult
6791Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6792 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6793 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006794 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6795 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6796
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006797 bool isFileScope
6798 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006799 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006800 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006801
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006802 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6803 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6804 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006805
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006806 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6807 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6808 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006809
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006810 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6811 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6812 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6813 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6814 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006815
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006816 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006817 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006818 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006819
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006820 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6821 // expressions are not lvalues.
6822
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006823 substmt.release();
6824 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006825}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006826
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006827Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6828 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006829 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6830 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006831 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6832 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006833 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006834 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006835
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006836 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6837 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6838 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006839 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006840 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6841 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6842
6843 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6844 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6845 if (!Dependent
6846 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6847 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6848 << TypeRange))
6849 return ExprError();
6850
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006851 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6852 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006853 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6854 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006855 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006856 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6857 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006858
6859 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6860 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6861 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6862 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6863 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6864 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6865 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6866 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6867 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6868 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6869 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6870 if(!AT)
6871 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6872 << CurrentType);
6873 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6874 } else
6875 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6876
6877 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6878 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6879 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6880 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6881 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6882 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6883 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6884 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6885
6886 // Record this array index.
6887 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6888 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6889 continue;
6890 }
6891
6892 // Offset of a field.
6893 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6894 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6895 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6896 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6897 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6898 continue;
6899 }
6900
6901 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6902 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6903 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6904 return ExprError();
6905
6906 // Look for the designated field.
6907 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6908 if (!RC)
6909 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6910 << CurrentType);
6911 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6912
6913 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6914 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6915 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6916 // (clause 9).
6917 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6918 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6919 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6920 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6921 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6922 << CurrentType))
6923 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6924 }
6925
6926 // Look for the field.
6927 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6928 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6929 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6930 if (!MemberDecl)
6931 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6932 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6933 OC.LocEnd));
6934
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006935 // C99 7.17p3:
6936 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6937 //
6938 // We diagnose this as an error.
6939 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6940 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6941 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6942 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6943 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6944 return ExprError();
6945 }
6946
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006947 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6948 // the base class indirections.
6949 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6950 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6951 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6952 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6953 Paths)) {
6954 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6955 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6956 B != BEnd; ++B)
6957 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6958 }
6959
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006960 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006961 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006962 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6963 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6964 unsigned n = Path.size();
6965 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6966 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6967 } else {
6968 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6969 }
6970 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6971 }
6972
6973 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6974 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6975 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6976}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006977
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006978Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6979 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6980 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6981 TypeTy *argty,
6982 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6983 unsigned NumComponents,
6984 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6985
6986 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6987 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6988 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6989 return ExprError();
6990
6991 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6992 if (!ArgTInfo)
6993 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6994
6995 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6996 RPLoc);
6997 }
6998
6999 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
7000 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
7001
7002 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
7003
7004 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7005 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7006 // a struct/union/class.
7007 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
7008 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
7009
7010 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7011 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
7012
7013 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
7014 // the offsetof designators.
7015 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
7016 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
7017 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
7018 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
7019
7020 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7021 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
7022 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7023 // a system header!
7024 if (NumComponents != 1)
7025 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7026 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
7027
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007028 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00007029 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007030
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00007031 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
7032 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7033 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007034
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007035 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
7036 // leaks like a sieve.
7037 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7038 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7039 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7040 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7041 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
7042 if (!AT) {
7043 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007044 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007045 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007046 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007047
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007048 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007049
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007050 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
7051 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007052 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007053
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007054 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
7055 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007056 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007057 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007058 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00007059 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007060 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7061
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007062 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
7063 OC.LocEnd);
7064 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007065 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007066
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007067 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007068 if (!RC) {
7069 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007070 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007071 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007072 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007073
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007074 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
7075 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00007076 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007077 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7078 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7079 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007080 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7081 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007082 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00007083 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007084
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00007085 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7086 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007087
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00007088 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007089 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007090 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00007091 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007092 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
7093
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007094 // C99 7.17p3:
7095 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7096 //
7097 // We diagnose this as an error.
7098 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7099 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7100 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7101 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7102 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7103 return ExprError();
7104 }
7105
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007106 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
7107 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007108 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00007109 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007110 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007111 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007112 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
7113 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007114 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
7115 // doesn't matter here.
7116 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007117 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007118 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007119 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007120 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007121
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007122 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
7123 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007124}
7125
7126
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007127Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7128 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
7129 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007130 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
7131 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
7132 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007133
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007134 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007135
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007136 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7137 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7138 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7139 return ExprError();
7140 }
7141
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007142 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
7143 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007144}
7145
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007146Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7147 ExprArg cond,
7148 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7149 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7150 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7151 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7152 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007153
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007154 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7155
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007156 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007157 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007158 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007159 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007160 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007161 } else {
7162 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7163 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7164 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7165 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007166 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7167 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7168 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007169
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007170 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7171 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007172 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7173 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007174 }
7175
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007176 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7177 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007178 resType, RPLoc,
7179 resType->isDependentType(),
7180 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007181}
7182
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007183//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7184// Clang Extensions.
7185//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7186
7187/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007188void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007189 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7190 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7191 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007192 if (BlockScope)
7193 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7194 else
7195 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007196}
7197
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007198void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007199 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007200 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007201
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007202 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007203 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007204 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007205
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007206 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007207 QualType RetTy;
7208 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007209 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007210 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007211 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007212 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7213 } else {
7214 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007215 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007216 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007217
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007218 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007219
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007220 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7221 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7222 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007223 return;
7224 }
7225
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007226 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7227 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7228 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7229 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7230 return;
7231 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007232
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007233 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007234 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7235 // ^ * { ... }
7236 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007237 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7238 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007239
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007240 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007241 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007242 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7243 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7244 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7245 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007246 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7247 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7248 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7249 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7250 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007251 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007252 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007253
7254 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7255 // ^ fntype { ... }
7256 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7257 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7258 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7259 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7260 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7261 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7262 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007263 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007264 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007265 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007266
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007267 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7268 if (!Params.empty())
7269 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007270
7271 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007272 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007273
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007274 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007275 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7276 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7277 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7278 }
7279
7280 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7281 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007282 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007283 return;
7284
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007285 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7286 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7287
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007288 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007289 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7290 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7291
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007292 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007293 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7294 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7295 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7296
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007297 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007298 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007299 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007300}
7301
7302/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7303/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7304void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007305 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007306 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007307 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007308 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007309}
7310
7311/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7312/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007313Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7314 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007315 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7316 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7317 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007318
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007319 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007320
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007321 PopDeclContext();
7322
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007323 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007324 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7325 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007326
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007327 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007328 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007329
7330 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7331 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7332 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7333
7334 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7335 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7336
7337 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7338 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7339 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7340 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7341
7342 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7343 // preserve its sugar structure.
7344 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7345 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7346 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7347
7348 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7349 } else {
7350 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7351 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7352 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7353 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7354 FPT->isVariadic(),
7355 /*quals*/ 0,
7356 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7357 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7358 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7359 FPT->exception_begin(),
7360 Ext);
7361 }
7362
7363 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7364 } else {
7365 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7366 false, false, 0, 0,
7367 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7368 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007369
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007370 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007371 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7372 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007373 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007374
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007375 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007376 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007377 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007378
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007379 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007380
7381 bool Good = true;
7382 // Check goto/label use.
7383 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7384 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7385 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7386
7387 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7388 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7389 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7390 continue;
7391
7392 // Emit error.
7393 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7394 Good = false;
7395 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007396 if (!Good) {
7397 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007398 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007399 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007400
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007401 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007402 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7403 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7404 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007405
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007406 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7407 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007408 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007409 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007410}
7411
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007412Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7413 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7414 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007415 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007416 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7417 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007418
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007419 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007420
7421 // Get the va_list type
7422 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007423 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7424 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7425 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7426 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007427 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007428 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7429 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7430 } else {
7431 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7432 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007433 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007434 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007435 return ExprError();
7436 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007437
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007438 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7439 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007440 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7441 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007442 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007443 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007444
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007445 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007446 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007447
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007448 expr.release();
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00007449 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E,
7450 T.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007451 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007452}
7453
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007454Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007455 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7456 // pointers on the target.
7457 QualType Ty;
7458 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7459 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7460 else
7461 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7462
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007463 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007464}
7465
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007466static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007467 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007468 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7469 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007470
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007471 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7472 if (!PT)
7473 return;
7474
7475 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7476 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7477 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7478 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7479 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7480 return;
7481 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007482
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007483 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7484 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7485 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7486 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007487
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007488 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007489}
7490
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007491bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7492 SourceLocation Loc,
7493 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007494 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7495 bool *Complained) {
7496 if (Complained)
7497 *Complained = false;
7498
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007499 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7500 bool isInvalid = false;
7501 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007502 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007503
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007504 switch (ConvTy) {
7505 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7506 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007507 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007508 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7509 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007510 case IntToPointer:
7511 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7512 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007513 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007514 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007515 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7516 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007517 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7518 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7519 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007520 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7521 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7522 break;
7523 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007524 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7525 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7526 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7527 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7528 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7529 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7530 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7531 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7532 // C++ semantics.
7533 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7534 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7535 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007536 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7537 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007538 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007539 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007540 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007541 case IntToBlockPointer:
7542 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7543 break;
7544 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007545 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007546 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007547 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007548 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007549 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7550 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7551 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007552 case IncompatibleVectors:
7553 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7554 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007555 case Incompatible:
7556 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7557 isInvalid = true;
7558 break;
7559 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007560
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007561 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7562 switch (Action) {
7563 case AA_Assigning:
7564 case AA_Initializing:
7565 // The destination type comes first.
7566 FirstType = DstType;
7567 SecondType = SrcType;
7568 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007569
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007570 case AA_Returning:
7571 case AA_Passing:
7572 case AA_Converting:
7573 case AA_Sending:
7574 case AA_Casting:
7575 // The source type comes first.
7576 FirstType = SrcType;
7577 SecondType = DstType;
7578 break;
7579 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007580
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007581 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007582 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007583 if (Complained)
7584 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007585 return isInvalid;
7586}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007587
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007588bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007589 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7590 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7591 if (Result)
7592 *Result = ICEResult;
7593 return false;
7594 }
7595
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007596 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7597
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007598 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007599 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7600 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7601
7602 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7603 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7604 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7605 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7606 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7607 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7608 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007609
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007610 return true;
7611 }
7612
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007613 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7614 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007615
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007616 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7617 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7618 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007619
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007620 if (Result)
7621 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7622 return false;
7623}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007624
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007625void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007626Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007627 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7628 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007629}
7630
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007631void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007632Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7633 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7634 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7635 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007636
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007637 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7638 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7639 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7640 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7641 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007642 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007643 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7644 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7645 I != IEnd; ++I)
7646 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7647 }
7648
7649 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7650 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7651 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7652 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7653 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7654 I != IEnd; ++I)
7655 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7656 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007657 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007658
7659 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7660 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7661 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7662 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007663 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007664 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7665 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7666 ExprTemporaries.end());
7667
7668 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7669 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007670}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007671
7672/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7673///
7674/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7675/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7676/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7677/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7678///
7679/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7680///
7681/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7682void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7683 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007684
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007685 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007686 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007687
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007688 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7689 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7690 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7691 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007692 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007693 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007694 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007695 return;
7696 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007697
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007698 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7699 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007700
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007701 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7702 // an instantiation.
7703 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7704 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007705
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007706 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007707 case Unevaluated:
7708 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7709 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007710
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007711 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7712 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7713 // "used"; handle this below.
7714 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007715
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007716 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7717 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7718 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7719 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007720 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007721 return;
7722 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007723
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007724 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007725 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007726 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007727 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007728 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007729 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007730 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007731 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007732 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007733 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7734 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007735
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007736 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007737 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007738 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007739 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007740 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7741 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007742 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7743 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7744 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007745 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007746 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007747 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7748 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007749 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007750 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007751 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007752 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007753 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007754 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7755 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7756 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7757 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7758 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007759 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007760 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007761 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007762 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007763 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7764 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7765 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007766 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007767 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007768 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7769 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007770
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007771 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7772 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7773 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7774 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7775 Loc));
7776 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007777 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007778 Loc));
7779 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007780 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007781
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007782 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007783 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007784
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007785 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007786 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007787
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007788 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007789 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007790 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007791 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7792 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7793 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7794 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7795 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7796 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7797 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7798 }
7799 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007800
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007801 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007802
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007803 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007804 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007805 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007806}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007807
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007808namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007809 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007810 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007811 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007812 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7813 Sema &S;
7814 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007815
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007816 public:
7817 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007818
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007819 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007820
7821 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7822 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007823 };
7824}
7825
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007826bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7827 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007828 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7829 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7830 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007831
7832 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007833}
7834
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007835bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007836 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7837 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7838 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007839 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7840 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007841 }
7842
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007843 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007844}
7845
7846void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7847 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007848 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007849}
7850
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007851/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7852/// of the program being compiled.
7853///
7854/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007855/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007856/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7857/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7858/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7859/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007860/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007861/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007862///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007863/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7864/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7865/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7866/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007867bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007868 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7869 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7870 case Unevaluated:
7871 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7872 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007873
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007874 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7875 Diag(Loc, PD);
7876 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007877
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007878 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7879 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7880 break;
7881 }
7882
7883 return false;
7884}
7885
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007886bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7887 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7888 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7889 return false;
7890
7891 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7892 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7893 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7894 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007895
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007896 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007897 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007898 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7899 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007900 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007901 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7902 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7903 return true;
7904
7905 return false;
7906}
7907
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007908// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7909// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7910void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7911 SourceLocation Loc;
7912
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007913 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7914
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007915 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7916 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7917 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7918 return;
7919
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007920 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7921 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7922 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7923 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7924
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007925 // self = [<foo> init...]
7926 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7927 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7928 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7929
7930 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7931 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7932 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7933 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7934 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007935
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007936 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7937 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7938 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7939 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7940 return;
7941
7942 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7943 } else {
7944 // Not an assignment.
7945 return;
7946 }
7947
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007948 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007949 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007950
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007951 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007952 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007953 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007954 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7955 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7956 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007957}
7958
7959bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7960 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7961
7962 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007963 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007964
7965 QualType T = E->getType();
7966
7967 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7968 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7969 return true;
7970 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7971 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7972 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7973 return true;
7974 }
7975 }
7976
7977 return false;
7978}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007979
7980Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7981 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007982 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7983 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007984 return ExprError();
7985
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007986 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7987 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7988 return ExprError();
7989 }
7990
7991 return Owned(Sub);
7992}